agora inbox for [email protected]  
help / color / mirror / Atom feed
[PATCH v23 2/8] Row pattern recognition patch (parse/analysis).
397+ messages / 2 participants
[nested] [flat]

* [PATCH v23 2/8] Row pattern recognition patch (parse/analysis).
@ 2024-10-25 03:56 Tatsuo Ishii <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Tatsuo Ishii @ 2024-10-25 03:56 UTC (permalink / raw)

---
 src/backend/parser/parse_agg.c    |   7 +
 src/backend/parser/parse_clause.c | 297 +++++++++++++++++++++++++++++-
 src/backend/parser/parse_expr.c   |   6 +
 src/backend/parser/parse_func.c   |   3 +
 4 files changed, 312 insertions(+), 1 deletion(-)

diff --git a/src/backend/parser/parse_agg.c b/src/backend/parser/parse_agg.c
index efa730c167..a80263f90d 100644
--- a/src/backend/parser/parse_agg.c
+++ b/src/backend/parser/parse_agg.c
@@ -580,6 +580,10 @@ check_agglevels_and_constraints(ParseState *pstate, Node *expr)
 			errkind = true;
 			break;
 
+		case EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE:
+			errkind = true;
+			break;
+
 			/*
 			 * There is intentionally no default: case here, so that the
 			 * compiler will warn if we add a new ParseExprKind without
@@ -970,6 +974,9 @@ transformWindowFuncCall(ParseState *pstate, WindowFunc *wfunc,
 		case EXPR_KIND_CYCLE_MARK:
 			errkind = true;
 			break;
+		case EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE:
+			errkind = true;
+			break;
 
 			/*
 			 * There is intentionally no default: case here, so that the
diff --git a/src/backend/parser/parse_clause.c b/src/backend/parser/parse_clause.c
index 4c97690908..a6d2f7f4ba 100644
--- a/src/backend/parser/parse_clause.c
+++ b/src/backend/parser/parse_clause.c
@@ -98,7 +98,14 @@ static WindowClause *findWindowClause(List *wclist, const char *name);
 static Node *transformFrameOffset(ParseState *pstate, int frameOptions,
 								  Oid rangeopfamily, Oid rangeopcintype, Oid *inRangeFunc,
 								  Node *clause);
-
+static void transformRPR(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc, WindowDef *windef,
+						 List **targetlist);
+static List *transformDefineClause(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc, WindowDef *windef,
+								   List **targetlist);
+static void transformPatternClause(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc,
+								   WindowDef *windef);
+static List *transformMeasureClause(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc,
+									WindowDef *windef);
 
 /*
  * transformFromClause -
@@ -2956,6 +2963,10 @@ transformWindowDefinitions(ParseState *pstate,
 											 rangeopfamily, rangeopcintype,
 											 &wc->endInRangeFunc,
 											 windef->endOffset);
+
+		/* Process Row Pattern Recognition related clauses */
+		transformRPR(pstate, wc, windef, targetlist);
+
 		wc->winref = winref;
 
 		result = lappend(result, wc);
@@ -3823,3 +3834,287 @@ transformFrameOffset(ParseState *pstate, int frameOptions,
 
 	return node;
 }
+
+/*
+ * transformRPR
+ *		Process Row Pattern Recognition related clauses
+ */
+static void
+transformRPR(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc, WindowDef *windef,
+			 List **targetlist)
+{
+	/*
+	 * Window definition exists?
+	 */
+	if (windef == NULL)
+		return;
+
+	/*
+	 * Row Pattern Common Syntax clause exists?
+	 */
+	if (windef->rpCommonSyntax == NULL)
+		return;
+
+	/* Check Frame option. Frame must start at current row */
+	if ((wc->frameOptions & FRAMEOPTION_START_CURRENT_ROW) == 0)
+		ereport(ERROR,
+				(errcode(ERRCODE_SYNTAX_ERROR),
+				 errmsg("FRAME must start at current row when row patttern recognition is used")));
+
+	/* Transform AFTER MACH SKIP TO clause */
+	wc->rpSkipTo = windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpSkipTo;
+
+	/* Transform AFTER MACH SKIP TO variable */
+	wc->rpSkipVariable = windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpSkipVariable;
+
+	/* Transform SEEK or INITIAL clause */
+	wc->initial = windef->rpCommonSyntax->initial;
+
+	/* Transform DEFINE clause into list of TargetEntry's */
+	wc->defineClause = transformDefineClause(pstate, wc, windef, targetlist);
+
+	/* Check PATTERN clause and copy to patternClause */
+	transformPatternClause(pstate, wc, windef);
+
+	/* Transform MEASURE clause */
+	transformMeasureClause(pstate, wc, windef);
+}
+
+/*
+ * transformDefineClause
+ *		Process DEFINE clause and transform ResTarget into list of
+ *		TargetEntry.
+ *
+ * XXX we only support column reference in row pattern definition search
+ * condition, e.g. "price". <row pattern definition variable name>.<column
+ * reference> is not supported, e.g. "A.price".
+ */
+static List *
+transformDefineClause(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc, WindowDef *windef,
+					  List **targetlist)
+{
+	/* DEFINE variable name initials */
+	static char *defineVariableInitials = "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz";
+
+	ListCell   *lc,
+			   *l;
+	ResTarget  *restarget,
+			   *r;
+	List	   *restargets;
+	List	   *defineClause;
+	char	   *name;
+	int			initialLen;
+	int			i;
+
+	/*
+	 * If Row Definition Common Syntax exists, DEFINE clause must exist. (the
+	 * raw parser should have already checked it.)
+	 */
+	Assert(windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs != NULL);
+
+	/*
+	 * Check and add "A AS A IS TRUE" if pattern variable is missing in DEFINE
+	 * per the SQL standard.
+	 */
+	restargets = NIL;
+	foreach(lc, windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpPatterns)
+	{
+		A_Expr	   *a;
+		bool		found = false;
+
+		if (!IsA(lfirst(lc), A_Expr))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					errmsg("node type is not A_Expr"));
+
+		a = (A_Expr *) lfirst(lc);
+		name = strVal(a->lexpr);
+
+		foreach(l, windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs)
+		{
+			restarget = (ResTarget *) lfirst(l);
+
+			if (!strcmp(restarget->name, name))
+			{
+				found = true;
+				break;
+			}
+		}
+
+		if (!found)
+		{
+			/*
+			 * "name" is missing. So create "name AS name IS TRUE" ResTarget
+			 * node and add it to the temporary list.
+			 */
+			A_Const    *n;
+
+			restarget = makeNode(ResTarget);
+			n = makeNode(A_Const);
+			n->val.boolval.type = T_Boolean;
+			n->val.boolval.boolval = true;
+			n->location = -1;
+			restarget->name = pstrdup(name);
+			restarget->indirection = NIL;
+			restarget->val = (Node *) n;
+			restarget->location = -1;
+			restargets = lappend((List *) restargets, restarget);
+		}
+	}
+
+	if (list_length(restargets) >= 1)
+	{
+		/* add missing DEFINEs */
+		windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs =
+			list_concat(windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs, restargets);
+		list_free(restargets);
+	}
+
+	/*
+	 * Check for duplicate row pattern definition variables.  The standard
+	 * requires that no two row pattern definition variable names shall be
+	 * equivalent.
+	 */
+	restargets = NIL;
+	foreach(lc, windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs)
+	{
+		restarget = (ResTarget *) lfirst(lc);
+		name = restarget->name;
+
+		/*
+		 * Add DEFINE expression (Restarget->val) to the targetlist as a
+		 * TargetEntry if it does not exist yet. Planner will add the column
+		 * ref var node to the outer plan's target list later on. This makes
+		 * DEFINE expression could access the outer tuple while evaluating
+		 * PATTERN.
+		 *
+		 * XXX: adding whole expressions of DEFINE to the plan.targetlist is
+		 * not so good, because it's not necessary to evalute the expression
+		 * in the target list while running the plan. We should extract the
+		 * var nodes only then add them to the plan.targetlist.
+		 */
+		findTargetlistEntrySQL99(pstate, (Node *) restarget->val,
+								 targetlist, EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE);
+
+		/*
+		 * Make sure that the row pattern definition search condition is a
+		 * boolean expression.
+		 */
+		transformWhereClause(pstate, restarget->val,
+							 EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE, "DEFINE");
+
+		foreach(l, restargets)
+		{
+			char	   *n;
+
+			r = (ResTarget *) lfirst(l);
+			n = r->name;
+
+			if (!strcmp(n, name))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_SYNTAX_ERROR),
+						 errmsg("row pattern definition variable name \"%s\" appears more than once in DEFINE clause",
+								name),
+						 parser_errposition(pstate, exprLocation((Node *) r))));
+		}
+		restargets = lappend(restargets, restarget);
+	}
+	list_free(restargets);
+
+	/*
+	 * Create list of row pattern DEFINE variable name's initial. We assign
+	 * [a-z] to them (up to 26 variable names are allowed).
+	 */
+	restargets = NIL;
+	i = 0;
+	initialLen = strlen(defineVariableInitials);
+
+	foreach(lc, windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs)
+	{
+		char		initial[2];
+
+		restarget = (ResTarget *) lfirst(lc);
+		name = restarget->name;
+
+		if (i >= initialLen)
+		{
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_SYNTAX_ERROR),
+					 errmsg("number of row pattern definition variable names exceeds %d",
+							initialLen),
+					 parser_errposition(pstate,
+										exprLocation((Node *) restarget))));
+		}
+		initial[0] = defineVariableInitials[i++];
+		initial[1] = '\0';
+		wc->defineInitial = lappend(wc->defineInitial,
+									makeString(pstrdup(initial)));
+	}
+
+	defineClause = transformTargetList(pstate, windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpDefs,
+									   EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE);
+
+	/* mark column origins */
+	markTargetListOrigins(pstate, defineClause);
+
+	/* mark all nodes in the DEFINE clause tree with collation information */
+	assign_expr_collations(pstate, (Node *) defineClause);
+
+	return defineClause;
+}
+
+/*
+ * transformPatternClause
+ *		Process PATTERN clause and return PATTERN clause in the raw parse tree
+ */
+static void
+transformPatternClause(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc,
+					   WindowDef *windef)
+{
+	ListCell   *lc;
+
+	/*
+	 * Row Pattern Common Syntax clause exists?
+	 */
+	if (windef->rpCommonSyntax == NULL)
+		return;
+
+	wc->patternVariable = NIL;
+	wc->patternRegexp = NIL;
+	foreach(lc, windef->rpCommonSyntax->rpPatterns)
+	{
+		A_Expr	   *a;
+		char	   *name;
+		char	   *regexp;
+
+		if (!IsA(lfirst(lc), A_Expr))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					errmsg("node type is not A_Expr"));
+
+		a = (A_Expr *) lfirst(lc);
+		name = strVal(a->lexpr);
+
+		wc->patternVariable = lappend(wc->patternVariable, makeString(pstrdup(name)));
+		regexp = strVal(lfirst(list_head(a->name)));
+
+		wc->patternRegexp = lappend(wc->patternRegexp, makeString(pstrdup(regexp)));
+	}
+}
+
+/*
+ * transformMeasureClause
+ *		Process MEASURE clause
+ *	XXX MEASURE clause is not supported yet
+ */
+static List *
+transformMeasureClause(ParseState *pstate, WindowClause *wc,
+					   WindowDef *windef)
+{
+	if (windef->rowPatternMeasures == NIL)
+		return NIL;
+
+	ereport(ERROR,
+			(errcode(ERRCODE_SYNTAX_ERROR),
+			 errmsg("%s", "MEASURE clause is not supported yet"),
+			 parser_errposition(pstate, exprLocation((Node *) windef->rowPatternMeasures))));
+	return NIL;
+}
diff --git a/src/backend/parser/parse_expr.c b/src/backend/parser/parse_expr.c
index ef0b560f5e..b30b9f2675 100644
--- a/src/backend/parser/parse_expr.c
+++ b/src/backend/parser/parse_expr.c
@@ -577,6 +577,7 @@ transformColumnRef(ParseState *pstate, ColumnRef *cref)
 		case EXPR_KIND_COPY_WHERE:
 		case EXPR_KIND_GENERATED_COLUMN:
 		case EXPR_KIND_CYCLE_MARK:
+		case EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE:
 			/* okay */
 			break;
 
@@ -1860,6 +1861,9 @@ transformSubLink(ParseState *pstate, SubLink *sublink)
 		case EXPR_KIND_GENERATED_COLUMN:
 			err = _("cannot use subquery in column generation expression");
 			break;
+		case EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE:
+			err = _("cannot use subquery in DEFINE expression");
+			break;
 
 			/*
 			 * There is intentionally no default: case here, so that the
@@ -3199,6 +3203,8 @@ ParseExprKindName(ParseExprKind exprKind)
 			return "GENERATED AS";
 		case EXPR_KIND_CYCLE_MARK:
 			return "CYCLE";
+		case EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE:
+			return "DEFINE";
 
 			/*
 			 * There is intentionally no default: case here, so that the
diff --git a/src/backend/parser/parse_func.c b/src/backend/parser/parse_func.c
index 9b23344a3b..4c482abb30 100644
--- a/src/backend/parser/parse_func.c
+++ b/src/backend/parser/parse_func.c
@@ -2658,6 +2658,9 @@ check_srf_call_placement(ParseState *pstate, Node *last_srf, int location)
 		case EXPR_KIND_CYCLE_MARK:
 			errkind = true;
 			break;
+		case EXPR_KIND_RPR_DEFINE:
+			errkind = true;
+			break;
 
 			/*
 			 * There is intentionally no default: case here, so that the
-- 
2.25.1


----Next_Part(Fri_Oct_25_13_04_53_2024_648)--
Content-Type: Text/X-Patch; charset=us-ascii
Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit
Content-Disposition: inline;
 filename="v23-0003-Row-pattern-recognition-patch-rewriter.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44 Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 397+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 397+ messages in thread


end of thread, other threads:[~2026-07-06 04:44 UTC | newest]

Thread overview: 397+ messages (download: mbox mbox.gz follow: Atom feed)
-- links below jump to the message on this page --
2024-10-25 03:56 [PATCH v23 2/8] Row pattern recognition patch (parse/analysis). Tatsuo Ishii <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>

This inbox is served by agora; see mirroring instructions
for how to clone and mirror all data and code used for this inbox